blob: da7c6a2daec8e7fe9544d3f7f9dbb99412ea1707 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall7d384dd2009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner418f6c72008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregor314b97f2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlssonb633c4e2009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000381
382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCall4b7a8342010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor0da76df2009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000499/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
500/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
501/// actual member.
502///
503/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
504/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
505/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
506/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
507/// we found.
508///
509/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
510/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
511/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
512VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
513 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
515 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
516 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
517
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000519 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
520 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
521 do {
522 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000523 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000524 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000525 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 else {
527 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
528 break;
529 }
530 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000531 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533
534 return BaseObject;
535}
536
537Sema::OwningExprResult
538Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
539 FieldDecl *Field,
540 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
541 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
542 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 AnonFields);
545
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
547 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
548 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
549 // found via name lookup.
550 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000551 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 if (BaseObject) {
553 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
554 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000555 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
680/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
681///
682/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
683/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
684/// found template arguments.
685static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
686 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
687 TemplateName TName =
688 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
689
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000690 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
691 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCall0bd6feb2009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000692 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
693 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
694 I != E; ++I)
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000695 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCallb681b612009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000696
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000697 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000698}
699
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000700/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
701/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
702/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000703static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000704 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
705 return false;
706
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000707 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
708 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
709 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
710 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
711 if (!BaseRT) return false;
712
713 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000714 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000715 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
716 return false;
717 }
718
719 return true;
720}
721
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000722/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
723/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
724static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000725 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000726
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000727 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
728 if (!DC) return true;
729
730 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
731 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
732
733 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
734 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
735
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000736 return false;
737}
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000738
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
740/// the prospective base classes.
741static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
742 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
743 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745 return false;
746
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000747 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000748 if (!RD) return false;
749 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
750
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000751 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
752 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
753 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
754 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
755 if (!BaseRT) return false;
756
757 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
759 return false;
760 }
761
762 return true;
763}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000764
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765enum IMAKind {
766 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
767 IMA_Static,
768
769 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
770 IMA_Mixed,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
774 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
775
776 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
777 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
778 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
779
780 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
781 IMA_Instance,
782
783 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
784 IMA_Unresolved,
785
786 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
789
790 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
791 /// non-class context.
792 IMA_AnonymousMember,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
795 /// context is not an instance method.
796 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
797
798 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
799 /// class.
800 IMA_Error_Unrelated
801};
802
803/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
804/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
805/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
806/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
807/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
808/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
809static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
810 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000811 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000812
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000813 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000814 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000815 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
816 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000817
818 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
819 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
820
821 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
822 bool hasNonInstance = false;
823 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
824 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000825 NamedDecl *D = *I;
826 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
828
829 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
830 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
831 // that's a special case.
832 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
833 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
834 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
835 }
836 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
837 }
838 else
839 hasNonInstance = true;
840 }
841
842 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
843 // member reference.
844 if (Classes.empty())
845 return IMA_Static;
846
847 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
848 // an implicit member reference.
849 if (isStaticContext)
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
851
852 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
853 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
854 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
855 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000856 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000857 Classes))
858 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
859
860 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
861}
862
863/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
864static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
865 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
866 const LookupResult &R) {
867 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
868 SourceRange Range(Loc);
869 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
870
871 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
872 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
873 if (MD->isStatic()) {
874 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
875 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
876 << Range << R.getLookupName();
877 return;
878 }
879 }
880
881 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
882 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
883 return;
884 }
885
886 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000887}
888
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000889/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
890///
891/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000892bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000893 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
895
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000898 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
899 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000900 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000901 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
903 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000904
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000905 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
906 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
907 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
908 // dependent name.
909 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
910 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000911 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
912 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
913
914 if (!R.empty()) {
915 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
916 R.suppressDiagnostics();
917
918 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
919 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
920 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
921 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
922
923 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
924 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
925 // Actually quite difficult!
926 if (isInstance)
927 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000928 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000929 else
930 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
931
932 // Do we really want to note all of these?
933 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
934 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
935
936 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
937 return false;
938 }
939 }
940 }
941
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000942 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000943 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000944 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 if (!R.empty()) {
946 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
947 if (SS.isEmpty())
948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
949 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
950 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
951 else
952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
953 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
954 << SS.getRange()
955 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
956 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
957 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
958 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
959 << ND->getDeclName();
960
961 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
962 return false;
963 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000964
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000965 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
966 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
967 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
968 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
969 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
970 // to recover well anyway.
971 if (SS.isEmpty())
972 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
973 else
974 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
975 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
976 << SS.getRange();
977
978 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
979 return true;
980 }
981 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000982 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000984 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000986 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000987 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000988 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
989 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000990 return true;
991 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000992 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000993 }
994
995 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
996 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
997 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
998 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
999 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1000 << SS.getRange();
1001 return true;
1002 }
1003
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001004 // Give up, we can't recover.
1005 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1006 return true;
1007}
1008
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001009Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001010 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001011 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1012 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1013 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1014 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1015 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1016
1017 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001018 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001019
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001020 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001021
1022 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1023 DeclarationName Name;
1024 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1025 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001026 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1027 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001028
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001029 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001030
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001031 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1032 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001033 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1034 // (note: handled after lookup)
1035 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1036 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1037 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001038 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1039 // names a dependent type.
1040 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1041 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001042 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1043 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1044 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001045 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001046 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001047 TemplateArgs);
1048 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001049
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001050 // Perform the required lookup.
1051 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1052 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001053 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1054 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1055 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1056 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1057 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001058 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1059 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1060 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001061 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001062 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1063 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001064
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001065 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1066 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001067 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1068 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001069 if (E.isInvalid())
1070 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001071
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1073 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001074 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001075 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001076
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001077 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1078 return ExprError();
1079
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001080 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1081 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001083
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001085 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1087 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1088 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1089 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1090 }
1091
1092 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1093 // call, diagnose the problem.
1094 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001095 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001096 return ExprError();
1097
1098 assert(!R.empty() &&
1099 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001100
1101 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1102 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001103 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001104 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1105 R.clear();
1106 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1107 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1108 return move(E);
1109 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001110 }
1111 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001112
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001113 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1114 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1115
1116 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001117 // Warn about constructs like:
1118 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1119 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001120 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1121 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001122 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001123 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001124 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001125 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001126 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001127 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1128 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001129 break;
1130 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001131
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001132 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1133 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001134 }
1135 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001136 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001137 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1138 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1139 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1140 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1141 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1142 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001144 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001145
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001146 QualType T = Func->getType();
1147 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001148 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001149 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1150 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001152 }
1153 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001154
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001155 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1156 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1157 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1158 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1159 // class member access expression.
1160 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1161 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001162 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001164 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1165 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001166 }
1167
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (TemplateArgs)
1169 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001170
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1172}
1173
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001174/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1175Sema::OwningExprResult
1176Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1177 LookupResult &R,
1178 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1179 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1180 case IMA_Instance:
1181 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1182
1183 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1184 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1185 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1186 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1187
1188 case IMA_Mixed:
1189 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1190 case IMA_Unresolved:
1191 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1192
1193 case IMA_Static:
1194 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1195 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1196 if (TemplateArgs)
1197 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1198 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1199
1200 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1201 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1202 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1203 return ExprError();
1204 }
1205
1206 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1207 return ExprError();
1208}
1209
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001210/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1211/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1212/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1213/// this path.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001214Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001215Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001216 DeclarationName Name,
1217 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1218 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001219 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1221
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001222 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001223 return ExprError();
1224
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001225 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1226 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1227
1228 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1229 return ExprError();
1230
1231 if (R.empty()) {
1232 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1233 return ExprError();
1234 }
1235
1236 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1237}
1238
1239/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1240/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1241/// additional lookup.
1242///
1243/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1244/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1245///
1246/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1247Sema::OwningExprResult
1248Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001249 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001250 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001251 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001252
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001253 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1254 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1255 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1256 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1257 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1258
1259 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1260 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1261 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001262 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001263
1264 bool LookForIvars;
1265 if (Lookup.empty())
1266 LookForIvars = true;
1267 else if (IsClassMethod)
1268 LookForIvars = false;
1269 else
1270 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1271 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001272 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001274 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1276 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1277 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1278 if (IsClassMethod)
1279 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1280 << IV->getDeclName());
1281
1282 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1283 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1284 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1285 return ExprError();
1286
1287 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1288 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1289 return ExprError();
1290
1291 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1292 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1293 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1294 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1295
1296 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1297 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1298 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1299 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001300 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001301 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1302 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1303 SelfName, false, false);
1304 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1305 return Owned(new (Context)
1306 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1307 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1308 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001309 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001310 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001311 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001312 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1313 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1314 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1315 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1316 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1317 }
1318 }
1319
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001320 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1321 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1322 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1323 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1324 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1325 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1326 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1327 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1328 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001332 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1333 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001334}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001335
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001336/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1337///
1338/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1339///
1340/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1341/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1342/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1343/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1344///
1345/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1346/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1347/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1348/// the class declaring the member.
1349///
1350/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1351/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1352/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001353bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001354Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1355 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001356 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001357 NamedDecl *Member) {
1358 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1359 if (!RD)
1360 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001361
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001362 QualType DestRecordType;
1363 QualType DestType;
1364 QualType FromRecordType;
1365 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1366 bool PointerConversions = false;
1367 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1368 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001369
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001370 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1371 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1372 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1373 PointerConversions = true;
1374 } else {
1375 DestType = DestRecordType;
1376 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001377 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001378 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1379 if (Method->isStatic())
1380 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001381
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001382 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1383 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001384
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001385 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1386 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1387 PointerConversions = true;
1388 } else {
1389 FromRecordType = FromType;
1390 DestType = DestRecordType;
1391 }
1392 } else {
1393 // No conversion necessary.
1394 return false;
1395 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001396
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001397 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1398 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001399
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001400 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1401 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1402 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001403
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001404 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1405 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1406
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001407 bool isLvalue
1408 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1409
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001410 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001411 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001412 // class name.
1413 //
1414 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1415 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1416 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1417 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1418 //
1419 // class Base { public: int x; };
1420 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1421 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1422 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1423 //
1424 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1425 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1426 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1427 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001428 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001429 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1430 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1431 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1432
1433 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1434
1435 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1436 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1437 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1438 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001439 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001440 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001441 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001442 return true;
1443
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001444 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001445 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001446 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001447 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001448
1449 FromType = QType;
1450 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1451
1452 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1453 // we're done.
1454 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1455 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001456 }
1457 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001458
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001459 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001460
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001461 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1462 // down to the using declaration's type.
1463 //
1464 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1465 // class ever has member declarations.
1466 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1467 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1468 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1469 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1470
1471 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1472 // conversion is non-trivial.
1473 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1474 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001475 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001476 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001477 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001478 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001479
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001480 QualType UType = URecordType;
1481 if (PointerConversions)
1482 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001483 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001484 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001485 FromType = UType;
1486 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1487 }
1488
1489 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1490 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1491 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001493
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001494 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1495 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1496 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001498 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001500 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001501 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001502 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001503}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001504
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001505/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001506static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001507 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001508 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1509 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001510 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1511 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1512 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001513 if (SS.isSet()) {
1514 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1515 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001516 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001517
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001518 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001519 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001520}
1521
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001522/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1523/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1524/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1525/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001526Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1528 LookupResult &R,
1529 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1530 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001531 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1532
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001533 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001534
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001535 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1536 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001537 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001538 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001539 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001540 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001541 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001542
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001543 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1544 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001545 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1546 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001547 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1548 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001549 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1550 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1551 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1552 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001553 }
1554
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001555 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1556 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1557 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001558 SS,
1559 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1560 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001561}
1562
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001563bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001564 const LookupResult &R,
1565 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001566 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1567 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1568 return false;
1569
1570 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001571 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001572 return false;
1573
1574 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001575 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001576 return false;
1577
1578 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1579 // normal lookup:
1580 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1581 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1582
1583 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1584 // -- a declaration of a class member
1585 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1586 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001587 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001588 return false;
1589
1590 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1591 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1592 // using-declaration
1593 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1594 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1595 // turn off ADL anyway).
1596 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1597 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1598 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1599 return false;
1600
1601 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1602 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1603 // template
1604 // And also for builtin functions.
1605 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1606 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1607
1608 // But also builtin functions.
1609 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1610 return false;
1611 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1612 return false;
1613 }
1614
1615 return true;
1616}
1617
1618
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001619/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1620/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1621/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1622/// will in fact be used.
1623static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1624 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1625 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1626 return true;
1627 }
1628
1629 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1630 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1631 return true;
1632 }
1633
1634 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1635 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1636 return true;
1637 }
1638
1639 return false;
1640}
1641
1642Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001644 LookupResult &R,
1645 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001646 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1647 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001648 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001650
1651 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1652 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1653 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001654 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1655 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001656 return ExprError();
1657
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001658 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1659 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1660 // we've picked a target.
1661 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1662
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663 bool Dependent
1664 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001665 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001666 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001667 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1668 SS.getRange(),
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001669 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001670 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1671 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001672
1673 return Owned(ULE);
1674}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001675
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001676
1677/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1678Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1681 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001682 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1683 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684
1685 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1686 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001687
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001688 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1689 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1690 // a template argument list.
1691 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1692 << Template << SS.getRange();
1693 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1694 return ExprError();
1695 }
1696
1697 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1698 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1699 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001700 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001701 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001702 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001703 return ExprError();
1704 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001705
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001706 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1707 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1708 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1709 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001710 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001711 return ExprError();
1712
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001713 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1714 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001715 return ExprError();
1716
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001717 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1718 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1719 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1720 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001721 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001722 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1723 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1724 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001725 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001726 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001727 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1728 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1729 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1730 return ExprError();
1731 }
1732
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001733 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001734 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1735 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1736 return ExprError();
1737 }
1738
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001739 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001740 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001741 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001742 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001743 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001744 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1745 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001746 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001747
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001748 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001749 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1750 ExprTy, Loc, false,
1751 constAdded);
1752 QualType T = VD->getType();
1753 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !T->isDependentType() &&
1754 !T->isReferenceType()) {
1755 Expr *E = new (Context)
1756 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1757 SourceLocation());
1758
1759 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001760 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
1761 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001762 SourceLocation(),
1763 Owned(E));
1764 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001765 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001766 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahaniand7c73382010-06-08 17:52:11 +00001767 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001768 }
1769 }
1770 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001771 }
1772 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1773 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001774
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001775 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001776}
1777
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001778Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1779 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001780 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001781
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001782 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001783 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001784 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1785 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1786 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001787 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001788
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001789 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1790 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001791
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001792 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1793 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001794 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001795 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001796 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001797
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001798 QualType ResTy;
1799 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1800 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1801 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001802 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001803
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001804 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001805 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001806 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1807 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001808 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001809}
1810
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001811Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001812 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001813 bool Invalid = false;
1814 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1815 if (Invalid)
1816 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001817
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001818 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1819 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001820 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001821 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001822
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001823 QualType Ty;
1824 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1825 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1826 else if (Literal.isWide())
1827 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001828 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1829 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001830 else
1831 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001832
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001833 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1834 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001835 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001836}
1837
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1839 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001840 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1841 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001842 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001843 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001844 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001845 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001846 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001847
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001848 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001849 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1850 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001851 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001852
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001853 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001854 bool Invalid = false;
1855 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1856 if (Invalid)
1857 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001858
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001859 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001860 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1861 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001862 return ExprError();
1863
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001864 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001865
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001866 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001867 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001868 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001869 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001870 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001871 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001872 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001873 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001874
1875 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1876
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001877 using llvm::APFloat;
1878 APFloat Val(Format);
1879
1880 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001881
1882 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1883 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1884 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1885 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001886 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001887 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001888 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001889 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001890 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1891 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001892 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001893 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1894 }
1895
1896 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1897 << Ty
1898 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1899 }
1900
1901 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001902 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001903
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001904 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001905 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001906 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001907 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001908
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001909 // long long is a C99 feature.
1910 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001911 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001912 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1913
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001914 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001915 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001917 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1918 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1919 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001920 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1921 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001922 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001923 } else {
1924 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1925 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001926
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001927 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1928 // be an unsigned int.
1929 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1930
1931 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001932 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001933 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1934 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001935 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001936
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001937 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1938 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1939 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1940 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001941 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001942 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001943 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001944 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001945 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001946 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001947
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001948 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001949 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001950 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001951
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001952 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1953 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1954 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1955 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001956 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001957 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001958 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001959 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001960 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001961 }
1962
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001963 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001964 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001965 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001966
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001967 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1968 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1969 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1970 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001971 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001972 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001973 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001974 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001975 }
1976 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001977
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001978 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1979 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001980 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001981 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001982 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001983 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001984 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001985
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001986 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1987 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001988 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001989 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001990 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001991
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001992 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1993 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001994 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001995 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001996
1997 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001998}
1999
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002000Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2001 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002002 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002003 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002004 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002005}
2006
2007/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2008/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002009bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002010 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2011 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2012 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002013 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2014 return false;
2015
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002016 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2017 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2018 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2019 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2020 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2021 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2022
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002023 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002024 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002025 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002026 if (isSizeof)
2027 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2028 return false;
2029 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002030
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002031 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002032 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002033 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2034 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002035 return false;
2036 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002037
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002038 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002039 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2040 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002041 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002042
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002043 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002044 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002045 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002046 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2047 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002048 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002049
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002050 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2051 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2052 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2053 return true;
2054 }
2055
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002056 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002057}
2058
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002059bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2060 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2061 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002062
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002063 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002064 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2065 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002066
2067 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2068 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2069 return false;
2070
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002071 if (E->getBitField()) {
2072 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2073 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002074 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002075
2076 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2077 // bit-field.
2078 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002079 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002080 return false;
2081
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002082 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2083}
2084
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002085/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002086Action::OwningExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002087Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002088 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002090 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002091 return ExprError();
2092
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002093 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002094
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002095 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2096 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2097 return ExprError();
2098
2099 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002100 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002101 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2102 R.getEnd()));
2103}
2104
2105/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2106/// operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002107Action::OwningExprResult
2108Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002109 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2110 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2111 bool isInvalid = false;
2112 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2113 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2114 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2115 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002116 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002117 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2118 isInvalid = true;
2119 } else {
2120 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2121 }
2122
2123 if (isInvalid)
2124 return ExprError();
2125
2126 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2127 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2128 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2129 R.getEnd()));
2130}
2131
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002132/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2133/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2134/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002135Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002136Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2137 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002138 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002139 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002140
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002141 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002142 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2143 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2144 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002145 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002146
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002147 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2148 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2149 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2150
2151 if (Result.isInvalid())
2152 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2153
2154 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002155}
2156
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002157QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002158 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2159 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002160
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002161 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002162 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002163 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002164
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002165 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2166 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2167 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002168
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002169 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002170 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2171 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002172 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002173}
2174
2175
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002176
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002177Action::OwningExprResult
2178Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2179 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002180 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2181 switch (Kind) {
2182 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2183 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2184 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2185 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002186
Eli Friedmane4216e92009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002187 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002188}
2189
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002190Action::OwningExprResult
2191Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2192 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002193 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2194 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2195
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002196 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2197 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002198
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002199 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002200 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2201 Base.release();
2202 Idx.release();
2203 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2204 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2205 }
2206
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002207 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002208 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002209 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2210 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2211 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002212 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002213 }
2214
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002215 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2216}
2217
2218
2219Action::OwningExprResult
2220Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2221 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2222 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2223 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2224
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002225 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002226 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2227 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2228 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002229
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002230 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002231
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002232 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002233 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002234 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002235 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002236 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2237 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002238 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2239 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2240 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2241 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002242 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002243 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2244 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002245 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002246 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002247 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002248 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2249 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002250 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002251 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002252 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002253 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2254 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2255 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002256 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002257 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002258 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2259 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2260 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2261 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002262 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002263 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002264 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002265
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002266 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2267 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002268 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2269 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002270 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002271 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2272 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2273 // force the promotion here.
2274 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2275 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002276 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2277 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002278 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2279
2280 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2281 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002282 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002283 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2284 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2285 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2286 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002287 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2288 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002289 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2290
2291 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2292 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002293 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002294 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002295 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2296 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002297 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002298 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002299 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2300 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002301 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2302 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002303
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002304 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002305 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2306 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002307 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2308
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002309 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002310 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2311 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002312 // incomplete types are not object types.
2313 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2314 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2315 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2316 return ExprError();
2317 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002318
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002319 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002321 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2322 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002323 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002324
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002325 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002326 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002327 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2328 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2329 return ExprError();
2330 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002331
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002332 Base.release();
2333 Idx.release();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002334 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002335 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002336}
2337
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002338QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002339CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002340 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002341 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002342 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2343 // see FIXME there.
2344 //
2345 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2346 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002347 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002348
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002349 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002350 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002351
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002352 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002353 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2354 // to be selected.
2355 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002356
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002357 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2358 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002359 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002360
2361 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2362 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002363 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002364 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2365 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002366 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002367 do
2368 compStr++;
2369 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002370 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002371 do
2372 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002373 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002374 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002375
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002376 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002377 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2378 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002379 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2380 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002381 return QualType();
2382 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002383
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002384 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2385 // operates on.
2386 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002387 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002388
2389 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002390 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002391
2392 while (*compStr) {
2393 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2394 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2395 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2396 return QualType();
2397 }
2398 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002399 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002400
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002401 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002402 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002403 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002404 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002405 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002406 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002407 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002408 if (HexSwizzle)
2409 CompSize--;
2410
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002411 if (CompSize == 1)
2412 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002413
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002414 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002415 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002416 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2417 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2418 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2419 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002420 }
2421 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002422}
2423
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002424static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002425 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002426 const Selector &Sel,
2427 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002428
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002429 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002431 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002433
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002434 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2435 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002436 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002437 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002438 return D;
2439 }
2440 return 0;
2441}
2442
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002443static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002444 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002445 const Selector &Sel,
2446 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002447 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2448 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002449 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002450 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002451 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002452 GDecl = PD;
2453 break;
2454 }
2455 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002456 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002457 GDecl = OMD;
2458 break;
2459 }
2460 }
2461 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002462 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002463 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2464 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002465 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002466 if (GDecl)
2467 return GDecl;
2468 }
2469 }
2470 return GDecl;
2471}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002472
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002473Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002474Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2475 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002476 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2477 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2478 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2479 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2480 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2481
2482 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2483 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2484 //
2485 // T* t;
2486 // t.f;
2487 //
2488 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2489 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2490 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2491 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002492 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002493 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2494 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002495 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002496 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002497 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002498 return ExprError();
2499 }
2500 }
2501
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002502 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002503 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002504
2505 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2506 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002507 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002508 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2509 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2510 SS.getRange(),
2511 FirstQualifierInScope,
2512 Name, NameLoc,
2513 TemplateArgs));
2514}
2515
2516/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2517/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2518/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2519static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2520 Expr *BaseExpr,
2521 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002522 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002523 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002524 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2525 // diagnostics.
2526 if (!BaseExpr)
2527 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002528
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002529 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2530 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002531}
2532
2533// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2534// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2535// type. The restriction here is:
2536//
2537// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2538// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2539// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2540//
2541// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2542// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2543// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2544// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2545bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2546 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002547 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002548 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002549 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2550 if (!BaseRT) {
2551 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2552 // dependent.
2553 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2554 return false;
2555 }
2556 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002557
2558 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002559 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2560 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002561 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002562 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002563
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002564 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2565 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2566 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2567 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2568
2569 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2570 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2571
2572 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2573 return false;
2574 }
2575
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002576 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002577 return true;
2578}
2579
2580static bool
2581LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2582 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002583 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002584 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2585 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002586 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002587 << BaseRange))
2588 return true;
2589
2590 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2591 if (SS.isSet()) {
2592 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2593 // nested-name-specifier.
2594 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2595
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002596 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002597 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2598 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2599 return true;
2600 }
2601
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002602 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002603
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002604 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2605 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2606 << DC << SS.getRange();
2607 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002608 }
2609 }
2610
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002611 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2612 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002613
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002614 if (!R.empty())
2615 return false;
2616
2617 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2618 // for typos.
2619 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002620 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002621 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002622 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2623 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2624 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002625 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2626 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002627 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2628 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2629 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002630 return false;
2631 } else {
2632 R.clear();
2633 }
2634
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002635 return false;
2636}
2637
2638Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002639Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002640 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002641 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002642 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2643 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2644 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2645 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2646
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002647 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2648 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002649 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002650 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2651 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2652 Name, NameLoc,
2653 TemplateArgs);
2654
2655 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002656
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002657 // Implicit member accesses.
2658 if (!Base) {
2659 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2660 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2661 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2662 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2663 OpLoc, SS))
2664 return ExprError();
2665
2666 // Explicit member accesses.
2667 } else {
2668 OwningExprResult Result =
2669 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002670 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002671
2672 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2673 Owned(Base);
2674 return ExprError();
2675 }
2676
2677 if (Result.get())
2678 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002679
2680 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2681 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002682 }
2683
Sebastian Redl0aa866f2010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002684 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002685 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2686 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687}
2688
2689Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002690Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2691 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2692 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002693 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002694 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002695 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2696 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002697 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002698 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002699 if (IsArrow) {
2700 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2701 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2702 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002703 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002704
2705 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2706 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2707 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2708 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2709
2710 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002711 return ExprError();
2712
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002713 if (R.empty()) {
2714 // Rederive where we looked up.
2715 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2716 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2717 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002718
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002719 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002720 << MemberName << DC
2721 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002722 return ExprError();
2723 }
2724
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002725 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2726 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2727 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2728 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2729 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2730 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2731 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2732 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2733 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2734 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002735 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002736 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002737 return ExprError();
2738
2739 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2740 // result.
2741 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002742 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002743 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002744 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002745 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002746
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002747 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2748 // pick a member.
2749 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2750
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002751 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2752 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2753 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002754 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2755 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2757 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002758 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002759
2760 return Owned(MemExpr);
2761 }
2762
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002763 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002764 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2766
2767 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2768
2769 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2770 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2771 // error cases.
2772 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2773 return ExprError();
2774
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002775 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2776 if (!BaseExpr) {
2777 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002778 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2780
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002781 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2782 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2783 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2784 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002785 }
2786
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002787 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2788 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2789 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2790 // explicitly qualified.
2791 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2792 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2793 }
2794
2795 // Check the use of this member.
2796 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2797 Owned(BaseExpr);
2798 return ExprError();
2799 }
2800
2801 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2802 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2803 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002804 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2805 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002806 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2807 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2808
2809 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2810 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2811 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2812 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2813 else {
2814 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2815 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2816 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2817
2818 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2819 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2820
2821 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2822 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2823 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2824 }
2825
2826 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002827 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002828 return ExprError();
2829 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002830 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831 }
2832
2833 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2834 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2835 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002836 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002837 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2838 }
2839
2840 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2841 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2842 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002843 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002844 MemberFn->getType()));
2845 }
2846
2847 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2848 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2849 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002850 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002851 }
2852
2853 Owned(BaseExpr);
2854
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002855 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002856 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002857 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2858 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2859 else
2860 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2861 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002863 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2864 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002865 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002866 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002867}
2868
2869/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2870/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2871/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2872/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2873/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2874/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2875/// an ordinary member expression.
2876///
2877/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2878/// fixed for ObjC++.
2879Sema::OwningExprResult
2880Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002881 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002882 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002883 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002884 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002885
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002886 // Perform default conversions.
2887 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002888
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002889 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002890 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2891
2892 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2893 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002894
2895 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002896 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002897 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2898 // call, and continue on.
2899 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2900 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2901 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2902 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2903 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002904 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2905 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002906 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2907 ->isRecordType()))) {
2908 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2909 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2910 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002911 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002912
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002913 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002914 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002915 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2916 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002917 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002918
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002919 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2920 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2921 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2922 }
2923 }
2924 }
2925
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002926 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2927 // use that.
2928 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002929 if (IsArrow) {
2930 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2931 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2932 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002933 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002934 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002935 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2936 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002937 }
2938 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002939 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2940 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2941 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2942 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002943 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002944 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002945 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002946
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002947 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2948 // use that.
2949 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2950 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2951 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2952 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2953 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2954 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2955 }
2956 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002957
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002958 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002959
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002960 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002961 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002962 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2963 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2964 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2965 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2966 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2967 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2968 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2969 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2970 // Check the use of this method.
2971 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2972 return ExprError();
2973 }
2974 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2975 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2976 Selector SetterSel =
2977 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2978 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2979 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2980 if (!Setter) {
2981 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2982 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002983 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002984 }
2985 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2986 if (!Setter)
2987 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002988
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002989 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2990 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002991
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002992 if (Getter || Setter) {
2993 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002994
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002995 if (Getter)
2996 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2997 else
2998 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2999 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3000 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003001 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003002 PType,
3003 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3004 }
3005 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3006 << MemberName << BaseType);
3007 }
3008 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003009
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003010 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3011 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3012 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003013 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003014 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003015
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003016 if (IsArrow) {
3017 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003018 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003019 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3020 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003021 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3022 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3023 // struct MyRecord foo;
3024 // foo->bar
3025 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3026 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3027 // by now.
3028 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3029 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003030 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003031 IsArrow = false;
3032 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003033 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3034 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3035 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003036 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003037 } else {
3038 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3039 // type *foo;
3040 // foo.bar
3041 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3042 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3043 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3044 // the appropriate pointer type
3045 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3046 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3047 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3048 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3049 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003050 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003051 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3052 IsArrow = true;
3053 }
3054 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003055 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003056
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003057 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003058 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003059 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3060 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003061 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003062 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003063 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003064
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003065 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3066 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003067 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003068 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003069 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003070 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3071 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3072 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3073 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003074 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3075
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003076 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003077 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003078
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003079 if (!IV) {
3080 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3081 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3082 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003083 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003084 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003085 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003086 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3087 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003088 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3089 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003090 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003091 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003092 }
3093 }
3094
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003095 if (IV) {
3096 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3097 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3098 // error cases.
3099 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3100 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003101
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003102 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3103 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3104 return ExprError();
3105 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3106 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3107 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3108 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3109 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3110 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3111 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3112 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3113 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3114 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3115 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3116 // AST for a function decl.
3117 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003118 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003119 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3120 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3121 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3122 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3123 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3124 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003125
3126 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3127 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003128 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003129 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003130 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003131 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3132 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003133 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003134 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003135 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003136
3137 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3138 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003139 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003140 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003141 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003142 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003143 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003144 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003145 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003146 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003147 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3148 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003149 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003150 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003151
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003152 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003153 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003154 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3155 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3156 // Check the use of this declaration
3157 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3158 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003159
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003160 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3161 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3162 }
3163 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3164 // Check the use of this method.
3165 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3166 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003167
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003168 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003169 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3170 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3171 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003172 }
3173 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003174
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003175 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003176 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003177 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003178
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003179 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3180 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003181 if (!IsArrow)
3182 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3183 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003184 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003185
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003186 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003187 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003188 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3189 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003190 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003191 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003192 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003193
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003194 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003195 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003196 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003197 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3198 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003199 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003200 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003201 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003202 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003203
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003204 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3205 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3206
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003207 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003208}
3209
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003210/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3211/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3212/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3213/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3214/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3215///
3216/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3217/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3218/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3219/// only be called
3220/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3221/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3222/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3223Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3224 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3225 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003226 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003227 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3228 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3229 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3230 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3231 return ExprError();
3232
3233 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3234
3235 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3236 DeclarationName Name;
3237 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3238 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3239 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3240 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3241
3242 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3243
3244 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3245 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3246 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3247
3248 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3249 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3250
3251 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3252 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003253 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3254 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003255 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003256 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3257 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3258 Name, NameLoc,
3259 TemplateArgs);
3260 } else {
3261 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3262 if (TemplateArgs) {
3263 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3264 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003265
Douglas Gregorc96be1e2010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003266 // Re-derive the naming class.
3267 if (SS.isSet()) {
3268 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3269 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3270 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3271 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3272 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3273 } else {
3274 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3275 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3276 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3277 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3278 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3279 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003280 } else {
3281 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003282 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003283
3284 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3285 Owned(Base);
3286 return ExprError();
3287 }
3288
3289 if (Result.get()) {
3290 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3291 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3292 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3293 // call now.
3294 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3295 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor77549082010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003296 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003297
3298 return move(Result);
3299 }
3300 }
3301
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003302 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003303 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3304 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003305 }
3306
3307 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003308}
3309
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003310Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3311 FunctionDecl *FD,
3312 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3313 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3314 Diag (CallLoc,
3315 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3316 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003317 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003318 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3319 } else {
3320 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3321 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3322
3323 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003324 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3325 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003326
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003327 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3328 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregord6350ae2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003329 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003330
John McCallce3ff2b2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003331 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003332 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003333 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003334
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003335 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3336 InitializedEntity Entity
3337 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3338 InitializationKind Kind
3339 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3340 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3341 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3342
3343 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003344 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003345 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3346 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003347 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003348
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003349 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003350 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003351 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003352 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003353
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003354 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3355 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3356 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003357 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3358 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003359 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3360 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003361 }
3362
3363 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003364 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003365}
3366
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003367/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3368/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3369/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3370/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3371/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3372/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003373bool
3374Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003375 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003376 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003377 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3378 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003379 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003380 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3381 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003382 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003383
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003384 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3385 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3386 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3387 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3388 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003389 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003390 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003391 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003392 }
3393
3394 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3395 // them.
3396 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3397 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3398 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3399 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003400 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003401 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003402 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3403 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3404 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003405 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003406 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003407 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003408 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003409 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003410 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003411 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3412 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3413 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3414 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3415 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003416 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003417 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003418 if (Invalid)
3419 return true;
3420 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3421 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3422 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003423
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003424 return false;
3425}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003426
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003427bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3428 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3429 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3430 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3431 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3432 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003433 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003434 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3435 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3436 bool Invalid = false;
3437 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3438 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3439 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3440 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003441 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003442 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003443 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003444
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003445 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003446 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3447 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003448
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003449 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3450 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003451 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003452 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003453 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003454
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003455 // Pass the argument
3456 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3457 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3458 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003459
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003460
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003461 InitializedEntity Entity =
3462 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3463 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3464 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3465 SourceLocation(),
3466 Owned(Arg));
3467 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3468 return true;
3469
3470 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003471 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003472 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003473
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003474 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003475 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003476 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3477 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003478
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003479 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003480 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003481 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003482 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003483
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003484 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003485 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003486 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003487 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003488 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003489 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003490 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003491 }
3492 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003493 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003494}
3495
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003496/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003497/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3498/// locations.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003499Action::OwningExprResult
3500Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3501 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003502 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003503 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003504
3505 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3506 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003507
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003508 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003509 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner74c469f2007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003510 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003511
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003512 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003513 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3514 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3515 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3516 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3517 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003518 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003519 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3520 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003521
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003522 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3523 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003524
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003525 NumArgs = 0;
3526 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003527
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003528 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3529 RParenLoc));
3530 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003531
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003532 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003533 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003534 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3535 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003536 bool Dependent = false;
3537 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3538 Dependent = true;
3539 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3540 Dependent = true;
3541
3542 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003543 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003544 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3545
3546 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3547 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3548 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3549 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3550
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003551 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3552
3553 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3554 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3555 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3556 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3557 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3558 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3559 // method template.
3560 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003561 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3562 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003563 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003564
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003565 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3566 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003567 }
3568
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003569 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003570 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003571 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003572 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003573 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3574 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003575 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003576
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003577 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003578 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003579 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3580 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003581 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3582 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003583 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003584
3585 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3586 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003587 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3588 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003589
3590 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3591 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003592 TheCall.get(), 0))
3593 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003594
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003595 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003596 RParenLoc))
3597 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003598
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003599 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3600 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003601 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003602 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3603 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003604 }
3605 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003606 }
3607
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003608 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003609 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003610 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003611
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003612 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003613 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3614 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003615 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003616 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003617 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003618
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003619 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3620 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3621 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3622
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003623 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3624}
3625
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003626/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3627/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003628/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3629/// block-pointer type.
3630///
3631/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3632Sema::OwningExprResult
3633Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3634 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3635 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3636 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3637 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3638
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003639 // Promote the function operand.
3640 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3641
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003642 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3643 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003644 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3645 Args, NumArgs,
3646 Context.BoolTy,
3647 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003648
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003649 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3650 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3651 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3652 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003653 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003654 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003655 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3656 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003657 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003658 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003659 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003660 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003661 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003662 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003663 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3664 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3665
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003666 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003667 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003668 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3669 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003670 return ExprError();
3671
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003672 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003673 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003674
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003675 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003676 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003677 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003678 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003679 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003680 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003681
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003682 if (FDecl) {
3683 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3684 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3685 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6fb0aee2009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003686 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003687 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003688 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003689 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3690 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3691 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3692 }
3693 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003694 }
3695
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003696 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003697 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3698 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3699 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003700 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3701 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003702 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3703 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003704 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003705 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003706 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003707 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003708
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003709 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3710 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003711 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3712 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003713
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003714 // Check for sentinels
3715 if (NDecl)
3716 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003717
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003718 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003719 if (FDecl) {
3720 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3721 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003722
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003723 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003724 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3725 } else if (NDecl) {
3726 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3727 return ExprError();
3728 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003729
Anders Carlssonec74c592009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003730 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003731}
3732
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003733Action::OwningExprResult
3734Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3735 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003736 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003737 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003738 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003739
3740 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3741 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3742 if (!TInfo)
3743 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3744
3745 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3746}
3747
3748Action::OwningExprResult
3749Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3750 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3751 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003752 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003753
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003754 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003755 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003756 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3757 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003758 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3759 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003760 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003761 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003762 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003763 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003764
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003765 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003766 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003767 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003768 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003769 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003770 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3771 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3772 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3773 &literalType);
3774 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003775 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003776 InitExpr.release();
3777 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003778
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003779 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003780 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003781 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003782 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003783 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003784
3785 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003786
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003787 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003788 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003789}
3790
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003791Action::OwningExprResult
3792Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003793 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3794 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3795 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003796
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003797 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003798 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003799
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003800 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3801 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003802 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003803 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003804}
3805
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003806static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3807 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003808 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003809 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3810
3811 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3812 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003813 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3814 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahaniana7fa7cd2009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003815 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003816 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3817 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3818 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003819
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003820 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3821 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3822 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3823 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3824 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3825 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3826 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3827 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003828
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003829 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3830 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3831 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3832 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3833 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3834 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003835
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003836 // FIXME: Assert here.
3837 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3838 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3839}
3840
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003841/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003842bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003843 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003844 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003845 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003846 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003847 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3848 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003849
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003850 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003851
3852 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3853 // type needs to be scalar.
3854 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3855 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003856 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3857 return false;
3858 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003859
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003860 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003861 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003862 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3863 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003864 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003865 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3866 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003867 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003868 return false;
3869 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003870
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003871 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003872 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003873 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003874 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003875 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003876 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003877 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003878 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003879 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3880 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3881 break;
3882 }
3883 }
3884 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3885 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3886 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003887 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003888 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003889 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003890
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003891 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3892 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3893 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3894 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003895
3896 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003897 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003898 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3899 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003900 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003901 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003902
3903 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003904 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003905
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003906 if (castType->isVectorType())
3907 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3908 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3909 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3910
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003911 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3912 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003913
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003914 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003915 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3916 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3917 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3918 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3919 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3920 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3921 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3922 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3923 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3924 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003925 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003926
3927 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003928 return false;
3929}
3930
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003931bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3932 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003933 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003934
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003935 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003936 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003937 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003938 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003939 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003940 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003941 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003942 } else
3943 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003944 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003945 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003946
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003947 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003948 return false;
3949}
3950
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003951bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003952 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003953 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003954
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003955 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003956
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003957 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3958 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003959 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3960 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3961 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3962 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003963 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003964 return false;
3965 }
3966
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003967 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003968 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3969 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003970 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3971 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3972 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3973 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003974
3975 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3976 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3977 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003978
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003979 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003980 return false;
3981}
3982
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003983Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003984Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003985 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3986 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3987 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003988
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003989 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3990 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3991 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003992 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003993
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003994 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003995 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003996 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003997 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3998 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003999
4000 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4001}
4002
4003Action::OwningExprResult
4004Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4005 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4006 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4007
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004008 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004009 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004010 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004011 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004012 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004013
Douglas Gregord6e44a32010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004014 Op.release();
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004015 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004016 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssoncdb61972009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004017 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004018}
4019
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004020/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4021/// of comma binary operators.
4022Action::OwningExprResult
4023Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4024 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4025 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4026 if (!E)
4027 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004028
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004029 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004030
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004031 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4032 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4033 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004034
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004035 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4036}
4037
4038Action::OwningExprResult
4039Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4040 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004041 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004042 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004043 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004044
4045 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004046 // then handle it as such.
4047 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4048 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4049 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4050 return ExprError();
4051 }
4052
4053 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4054 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4055 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4056
4057 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4058 // braces instead of the original commas.
4059 Op.release();
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004060 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4061 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004062 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4063 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004064 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004065 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004066 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004067 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4068 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004069 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004070 }
4071}
4072
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004073Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004074 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004075 MultiExprArg Val,
4076 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004077 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4078 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004079 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4080 Expr *expr;
4081 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4082 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4083 else
4084 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004085 return Owned(expr);
4086}
4087
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004088/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4089/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004090/// C99 6.5.15
4091QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4092 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004093 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4094 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4095 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4096
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004097 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4098 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4099 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4100 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4101 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4102 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004103
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004104 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004105 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4106 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4107 << CondTy;
4108 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004109 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004110
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004111 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004112 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4113 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004114
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004115 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4116 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004117 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4118 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4119 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004120 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004121
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004122 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4123 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004124 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4125 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004126 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004127 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004128 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004129 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004130 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004131 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004132
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004133 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004134 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004135 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4136 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4137 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4138 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4139 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4140 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4141 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004142 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4143 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004144 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004145 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004146 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4147 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004148 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004149 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004150 // promote the null to a pointer.
4151 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004152 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004153 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004154 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004155 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004156 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004157 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004158 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004159
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004160 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4161 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4162 QuestionLoc);
4163 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4164 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004165
4166
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004167 // Handle block pointer types.
4168 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4169 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4170 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4171 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004172 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4173 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004174 return destType;
4175 }
4176 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004177 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004178 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004179 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004180 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4181 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4182 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004183 return LHSTy;
4184 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004185 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004186 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4187 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004188
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004189 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4190 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004191 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004192 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004193 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4194 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4195 // to get a consistent AST.
4196 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004197 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4198 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004199 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004200 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004201 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004202 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4203 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004204 return LHSTy;
4205 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004206
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004207 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4208 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4209 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004210 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4211 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004212
4213 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4214 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4215 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004216 QualType destPointee
4217 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004218 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004219 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4220 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4221 // Promote to void*.
4222 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004223 return destType;
4224 }
4225 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004226 QualType destPointee
4227 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004228 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004229 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004230 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004231 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004232 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004233 return destType;
4234 }
4235
4236 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4237 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4238 return LHSTy;
4239 }
4240 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4241 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4242 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4243 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4244 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4245 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4246 // to get a consistent AST.
4247 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004248 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4249 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004250 return incompatTy;
4251 }
4252 // The pointer types are compatible.
4253 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4254 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4255 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4256 // type.
4257 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4258 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004259 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4260 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004261 return LHSTy;
4262 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004263
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004264 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4265 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4266 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4267 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004268 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004269 return RHSTy;
4270 }
4271 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4272 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4273 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004274 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004275 return LHSTy;
4276 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004277
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004278 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004279 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4280 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004281 return QualType();
4282}
4283
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004284/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4285/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4286QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4287 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4288 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4289 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004290
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004291 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4292 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4293 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4294 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4295 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4296 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4297 return LHSTy;
4298 }
4299 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4300 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4301 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4302 return RHSTy;
4303 }
4304 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4305 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4306 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4307 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4308 return LHSTy;
4309 }
4310 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4311 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4312 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4313 return RHSTy;
4314 }
4315 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4316 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4317 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4318 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4319 return LHSTy;
4320 }
4321 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4322 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4323 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4324 return RHSTy;
4325 }
4326 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4327 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004328
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004329 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4330 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4331 return LHSTy;
4332 }
4333 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4334 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4335 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004336
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004337 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4338 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4339 // type. This allows
4340 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4341 // where B is a subclass of A.
4342 //
4343 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4344 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4345 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4346 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004347
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004348 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4349 // It could return the composite type.
4350 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4351 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4352 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4353 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4354 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4355 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4356 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4357 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4358 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4359 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4360 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4361 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4362 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4363 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004364 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004365 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4366 ;
4367 else {
4368 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4369 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4370 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4371 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4372 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4373 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4374 return incompatTy;
4375 }
4376 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4377 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4379 return compositeType;
4380 }
4381 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4382 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4383 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4384 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4385 QualType destPointee
4386 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4387 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4388 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4389 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4390 // Promote to void*.
4391 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4392 return destType;
4393 }
4394 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4395 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4396 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4397 QualType destPointee
4398 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4399 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4400 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4401 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4402 // Promote to void*.
4403 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4404 return destType;
4405 }
4406 return QualType();
4407}
4408
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004409/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004410/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004411Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4412 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4413 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4414 ExprArg RHS) {
4415 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4416 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004417
4418 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4419 // was the condition.
4420 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4421 if (isLHSNull)
4422 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004423
4424 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004425 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004426 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004427 return ExprError();
4428
4429 Cond.release();
4430 LHS.release();
4431 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004432 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004433 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004434 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004435}
4436
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004437// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004438// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004439// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4440// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4441// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004442Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004443Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4444 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004445
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004446 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4447 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4448 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4449 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4450 return Compatible;
4451 }
4452
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004453 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004454 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4455 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004456
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004457 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004458 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4459 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004460
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004461 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004462
4463 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4464 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4465 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004466 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004467 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004468 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004469
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004470 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4471 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004472 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004473 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004474 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004475 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004476
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004477 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004478 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4479 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004480 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004481
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004482 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004483 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004484 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004485
4486 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004487 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4488 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004489 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004490 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004491 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004492 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4493 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4494 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4495 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4496 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4497 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004498 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004499 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004500 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004501 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004502
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004503 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004504 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004505 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004506 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004507
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004508 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4509 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4510 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4511 // warning can be disabled.
4512 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4513 return ConvTy;
4514 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4515 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004516
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004517 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4518 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4519 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4520 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4521 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4522 do {
4523 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4524 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004525
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004526 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4527 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4528 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004529
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004530 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004531 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004532 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004533
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004534 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004535 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004536 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004537 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004538}
4539
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004540/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4541/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4542/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4543// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004544Sema::AssignConvertType
4545Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004546 QualType rhsType) {
4547 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004548
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004549 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004550 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4551 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004553 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4554 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4555 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004556
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004557 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004558
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004559 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004560 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004561 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004562
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004563 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4564 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4565 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4566 }
4567 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004568 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004569 return ConvTy;
4570}
4571
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004572/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4573/// for assignment compatibility.
4574Sema::AssignConvertType
4575Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004576 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4577 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004578 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4579 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004580 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004581 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004582 }
4583 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4584 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004585 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4586 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004587 return IncompatiblePointer;
4588 return Compatible;
4589 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004590 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004591 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004592 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004593 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4594 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4595 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4596 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4597 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4598 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004599
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004600 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4601 return Compatible;
4602 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4603 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004604 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004605}
4606
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004607/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4608/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004609/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4610///
4611/// int a, *pint;
4612/// short *pshort;
4613/// struct foo *pfoo;
4614///
4615/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4616/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4617/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4618/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4619///
4620/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004621/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004622///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004623Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004624Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004625 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4626 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004627 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4628 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004629
4630 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004631 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004632
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004633 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4634 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4635 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4636 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4637 return Compatible;
4638 }
4639
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004640 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4641 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4642 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4643 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4644 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4645 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4646 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004647 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004648 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004649 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004650 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004651 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004652 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4653 // to the same ExtVector type.
4654 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4655 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4656 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4657 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4658 return Compatible;
4659 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004660
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004661 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004662 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004663 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004664 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004665 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4666 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004667 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004668 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004669 }
4670 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004671 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004672
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004673 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4674 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004675 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004676
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004677 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004678 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004679 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004680
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004681 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004682 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004683
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004684 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004685 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004686 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4687 return Compatible;
4688 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004689 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004690 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4691 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004692 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004693
4694 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004695 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004696 return Compatible;
4697 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004698 return Incompatible;
4699 }
4700
4701 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4702 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004703 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004704
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004705 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004706 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004707 return Compatible;
4708
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004709 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4710 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004711
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004712 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004713 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004714 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004715 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004716 return Incompatible;
4717 }
4718
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004719 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4720 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4721 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004722
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004723 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004724 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004725 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4726 return Compatible;
4727 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004728 }
4729 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004730 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004731 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004732 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004733 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4734 return Compatible;
4735 }
4736 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4737 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4738 return Compatible;
4739 return Incompatible;
4740 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004741 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004742 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004743 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4744 return Compatible;
4745
4746 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004747 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004748
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004749 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004750 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004751
4752 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004753 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004754 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004755 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004756 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004757 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4758 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4759 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4760 return Compatible;
4761
4762 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4763 return PointerToInt;
4764
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004765 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004766 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004767 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4768 return Compatible;
4769 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004770 }
4771 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004772 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004773 return Compatible;
4774 return Incompatible;
4775 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004776
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004777 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004778 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004779 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004780 }
4781 return Incompatible;
4782}
4783
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004784/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4785/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004786static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004787 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4788 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4789 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004790 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004791 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004792 SourceLocation());
4793 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4794 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4795
4796 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4797 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004798 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004799 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004800 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004801}
4802
4803Sema::AssignConvertType
4804Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4805 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4806
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004807 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004808 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4809 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004810 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004811 return Incompatible;
4812
4813 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4814 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4815 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4816 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004817 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4818 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004819 it != itend; ++it) {
4820 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4821 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4822 // 1) void pointer
4823 // 2) null pointer constant
4824 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004825 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004826 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004827 InitField = *it;
4828 break;
4829 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004830
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004831 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004832 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004833 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004834 InitField = *it;
4835 break;
4836 }
4837 }
4838
4839 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4840 == Compatible) {
4841 InitField = *it;
4842 break;
4843 }
4844 }
4845
4846 if (!InitField)
4847 return Incompatible;
4848
4849 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4850 return Compatible;
4851}
4852
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004853Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004854Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004855 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4856 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4857 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4858 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4859 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004860 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004861 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004862 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004863 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004864 }
4865
4866 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4867 // structures.
4868 }
4869
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004870 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4871 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004872 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4873 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004874 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004875 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004876 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004877 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004878 return Compatible;
4879 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004880
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004881 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004882 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004883 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004884 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004885 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004886 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004887 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004888 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004889
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004890 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4891 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004892
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004893 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4894 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004895 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4896 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4897 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4898 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004899 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004900 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4901 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004902 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004903}
4904
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004905QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004906 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004907 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004908 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004909 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004910}
4911
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004912QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004913 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004914 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004915 QualType lhsType =
4916 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4917 QualType rhsType =
4918 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004919
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004920 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004921 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004922 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004923
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004924 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4925 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004926 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4927 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004928 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4929 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004930 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004931 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004932 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4933 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4934 return lhsType;
4935 }
4936
4937 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4938 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004939 }
4940 }
4941 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004942
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004943 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4944 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4945 bool swapped = false;
4946 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4947 swapped = true;
4948 std::swap(rex, lex);
4949 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4950 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004951
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004952 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004953 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004954 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4955 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4956 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004957 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004958 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4959 return lhsType;
4960 }
4961 }
4962 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4963 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4964 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004965 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004966 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4967 return lhsType;
4968 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004969 }
4970 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004971
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004972 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004973 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004974 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004975 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004976 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004977}
4978
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004979QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4980 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004981 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004982 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004983
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004984 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004985
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004986 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4987 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4988 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004989
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004990 // Check for division by zero.
4991 if (isDiv &&
4992 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004993 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004994 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004995
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004996 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004997}
4998
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004999QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005000 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005001 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5002 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5003 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5004 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5005 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005006
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005007 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005008
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005009 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5010 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005011
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005012 // Check for remainder by zero.
5013 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005014 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5015 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005016
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005017 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005018}
5019
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005020QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005021 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005022 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5023 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5024 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5025 return compType;
5026 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005027
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005028 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005029
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005030 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005031 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5032 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5033 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005034 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005035 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005036
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005037 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5038 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005039 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005040 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5041
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005042 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005043
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005044 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005045 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005046
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005047 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5048 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005049 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5050 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005051 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005052 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005053 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005054
5055 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5056 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5057 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005058 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5060 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5061 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5062 return QualType();
5063 }
5064
5065 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5066 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5067 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005068 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005069 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005070 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005071 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005072 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5073 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005074 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5075 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005076 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005077 return QualType();
5078 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005079 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005080 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005081 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5082 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5083 return QualType();
5084 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005085
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005086 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005087 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5088 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5089 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5090 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5091 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005092 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005093 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5094 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005095 return PExp->getType();
5096 }
5097 }
5098
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005099 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005100}
5101
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005102// C99 6.5.6
5103QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005104 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5105 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5106 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5107 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5108 return compType;
5109 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005110
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005111 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005112
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005113 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005114
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005115 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005116 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5117 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005118 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005119 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005120 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005121
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005122 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005123 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005124 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005125
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005126 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005127
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005128 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5129 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5130 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5131 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5132 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5133 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5134 return QualType();
5135 }
5136
5137 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5138 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5139 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5140 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5141 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005142 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005143 return QualType();
5144 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005145
5146 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5147 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5148 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005149 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005150 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005151 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005152 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005153 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005154
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005155 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005156 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005157 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5158 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5159 return QualType();
5160 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005161
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005162 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005163 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5164 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5165 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5166 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5167 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5168 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005169 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005170 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5171
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005172 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005173 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005174 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005175
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005176 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005177 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005178 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005179
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005180 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5181 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5182 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5183 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5184 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5185 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5186 return QualType();
5187 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005188
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005189 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5190 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5191 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5192 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005193 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005194 return QualType();
5195 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005196
5197 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5198 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5199 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5200 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5201 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005202 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5203 << rex->getSourceRange()
5204 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005205 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005206
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005207 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5208 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5209 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5210 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5211 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5212 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5213 return QualType();
5214 }
5215 } else {
5216 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5217 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5218 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5219 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5220 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5221 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5222 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5223 return QualType();
5224 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005225 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005226
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005227 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5228 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5229 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5230 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5231 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005232 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005233 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005234
5235 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005236 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5237 }
5238 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005239
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005240 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005241}
5242
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005243// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005244QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005245 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005246 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5247 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005248 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005249
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005250 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5251 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5252 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5253
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005254 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5255 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005256 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5257 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5258 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5259 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5260 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005261 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005262 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005263 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005264
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005265 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005266
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005267 // Sanity-check shift operands
5268 llvm::APSInt Right;
5269 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005270 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5271 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005272 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005273 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5274 else {
5275 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5276 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5277 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5278 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5279 }
5280 }
5281
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005282 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005283 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005284}
5285
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005286// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005287QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005288 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5289 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5290
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005291 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005292 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005293 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005294
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005295 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff30bf7712007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005296 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5297 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5298 else {
5299 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5300 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5301 }
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005302 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5303 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005304
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005305 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5306 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005307 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5308 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5309 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005310 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenek9ecede72009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005311 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005312 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5313 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5314 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5315 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenekb82dcd82009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005316 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5317 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005318 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005319
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005320 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5321 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5322 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5323 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005324
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005325 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5326 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005327 Expr *literalString = 0;
5328 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005329 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005330 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005331 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005332 literalString = lex;
5333 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005334 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5335 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005336 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005337 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005338 literalString = rex;
5339 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5340 }
5341
5342 if (literalString) {
5343 std::string resultComparison;
5344 switch (Opc) {
5345 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5346 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5347 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5348 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5349 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5350 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5351 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5352 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005353
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005354 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5355 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5356 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005357 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005358 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005359 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005360
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005361 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005362 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005363
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005364 if (isRelational) {
5365 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005366 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005367 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005368 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005369 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005370 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005371
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005372 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005373 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005374 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005375
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005376 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005377 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005378 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005379 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005380
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005381 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5382 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5383 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005384 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005385 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005386 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005387 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005388 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005389
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005390 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005391 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5392 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005393 if (!isRelational &&
5394 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5395 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5396 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5397 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5398 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5399 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5400 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5401 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5402 return ResultTy;
5403 }
5404 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005405 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5406 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5407 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5408 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5409 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5410 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005411 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005412 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005413 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005414 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005415 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005416 if (T.isNull()) {
5417 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5418 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5419 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005420 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005421 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005422 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005423 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005424 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005425 }
5426
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005427 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5428 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005429 return ResultTy;
5430 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005431 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5432 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5433 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5434 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5435 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5436 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5437 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5438 }
5439 } else if (!isRelational &&
5440 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5441 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5442 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5443 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5444 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5445 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5446 }
5447 } else {
5448 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005449 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005450 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005451 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005452 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005453 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005454 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005455 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005456
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005457 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005458 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005459 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005460 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005461 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5462 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005463 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005464 return ResultTy;
5465 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005466 if (LHSIsNull &&
5467 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5468 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005469 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005470 return ResultTy;
5471 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005472
5473 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005474 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005475 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5476 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005477 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5478 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5479 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5480 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5481 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5482 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5483 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5484 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005485 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005486 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005487 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005488 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005489 if (T.isNull()) {
5490 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005491 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005492 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005493 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005494 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005495 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005496 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005497 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005498 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005499
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005500 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5501 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005502 return ResultTy;
5503 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005504
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005505 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005506 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5507 return ResultTy;
5508 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005509
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005510 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005511 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005512 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5513 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005514
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005515 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005516 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005517 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005518 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005519 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005520 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005521 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005522 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005523 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005524 if (!isRelational
5525 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5526 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005527 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005528 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005529 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005530 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005531 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5532 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5533 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005534 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005535 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005536 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005537 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005538
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005539 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005540 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005541 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5542 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005543 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005544 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005545 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005546 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005547
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005548 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5549 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005550 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005551 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005552 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005553 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005554 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005555 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005556 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005557 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005558 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5559 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005560 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005561 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005562 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005563 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005564 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005565 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5566 if (RHSIsNull) {
5567 if (isRelational)
5568 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5569 } else if (isRelational)
5570 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5571 else
5572 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005573
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005574 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005575 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005576 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005577 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005578 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005579 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005580 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005581 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005582 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5583 if (LHSIsNull) {
5584 if (isRelational)
5585 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5586 } else if (isRelational)
5587 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5588 else
5589 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005590
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005591 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005592 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005593 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005594 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005595 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005596 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005597 }
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005598 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005599 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5600 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005601 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005602 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005603 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005604 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5605 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005606 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005607 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005608 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005609 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005610}
5611
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005612/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005613/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005614/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5615/// types.
5616QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005617 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005618 bool isRelational) {
5619 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5620 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005621 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005622 if (vType.isNull())
5623 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005624
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005625 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5626 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005627
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005628 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5629 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5630 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5631 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5632 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5633 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5634 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005635 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005636 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005637
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005638 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5639 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5640 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005641 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005642 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005643
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005644 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5645 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5646 // elements for floating point vectors.
5647 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5648 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005649
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005650 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005651 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005652 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005653 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005654 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005655 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5656
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005657 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005658 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005659 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5660}
5661
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005662inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005663 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff3e5e5562007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005664 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005665 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005666
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005667 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005668
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005669 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005670 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005671 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005672}
5673
5674inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005675 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005676 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5677 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5678 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005679
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005680 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5681 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005682
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005683 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005684 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005685
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005686 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5687 // non-overloadable operands.
5688
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005689 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5690 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005691 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5692 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5693 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005694 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005695
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005696 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5697 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5698 // The result is a bool.
5699 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005700}
5701
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005702/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5703/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5704/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5705///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005706static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005707 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5708 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5709 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5710 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005711 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005712 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5713 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5714 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5715 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005716 }
5717 }
5718 return false;
5719}
5720
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005721/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5722/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5723static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005724 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005725 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005726 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005727 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5728 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005729 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5730 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005731
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005732 unsigned Diag = 0;
5733 bool NeedType = false;
5734 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005735 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005736 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005737 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5738 NeedType = true;
5739 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005740 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005741 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5742 NeedType = true;
5743 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005744 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005745 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5746 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005747 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5748 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005749 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005750 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5751 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005752 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5753 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005754 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5755 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005756 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005757 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005758 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005759 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005760 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5761 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005762 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005763 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5764 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005765 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5766 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5767 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005768 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5769 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5770 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005771 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5772 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5773 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005774 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005775
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005776 SourceRange Assign;
5777 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5778 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005779 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005780 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005781 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005782 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005783 return true;
5784}
5785
5786
5787
5788// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005789QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5790 SourceLocation Loc,
5791 QualType CompoundType) {
5792 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5793 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005794 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005795
5796 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5797 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005798 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005799 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005800 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005801 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005802 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5803 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5804 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5805 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5806 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5807 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5808 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5809 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5810 }
5811 }
5812
5813 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005814 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5815 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5816 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005817 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005818 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005819 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005820 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005821
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005822 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5823 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5824 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005825 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005826 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5827 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5828 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5829 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5830 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005831 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005832 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005833 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5834 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5835 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005836 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5837 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005838 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5839 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5840 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005841 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005842 }
5843 } else {
5844 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005845 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005846 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005847
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005848 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005849 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005850 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005851
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005852 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5853 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005854 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005855 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5856 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005857 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005858 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005859 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005860}
5861
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005862// C99 6.5.17
5863QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005864 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005865 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5866 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5867 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005868
5869 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5870 // incomplete in C++).
5871
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005872 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005873}
5874
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005875/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5876/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005877QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005878 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005879 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5880 return Context.DependentTy;
5881
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005882 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5883 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005884
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005885 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5886 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5887 if (!isInc) {
5888 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5889 return QualType();
5890 }
5891 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5892 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5893 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005894 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005895 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5896 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005897
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005898 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005899 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005900 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5901 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5902 << Op->getSourceRange();
5903 return QualType();
5904 }
5905
5906 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005907 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005908 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005909 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5910 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5911 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5912 return QualType();
5913 }
5914
5915 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005916 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005917 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005918 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005919 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005920 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005921 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005922 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005923 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005924 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5925 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5926 return QualType();
5927 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005928 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005929 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5930 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005931 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005932 } else {
5933 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005934 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005935 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005936 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005937 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005938 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005939 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005940 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005941 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5942 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5943 // operand.
5944 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5945 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005946}
5947
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005948/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005949/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005950/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5951/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5952/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5953/// - &(x) => x
5954/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5955/// - &s.xx => s
5956/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5957/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5958/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5959/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005960static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005961 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005962 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005963 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005964 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005965 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5966 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5967 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005968 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005969 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005970 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005971 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005972 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005973 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5974 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005975 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5976 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5977 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5978 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5979 }
5980 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005981 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005982 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5983 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005984
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005985 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005986 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5987 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5988 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5989 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5990 default:
5991 return 0;
5992 }
5993 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005994 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005995 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005996 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005997 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5998 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005999 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006000 default:
6001 return 0;
6002 }
6003}
6004
6005/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006006/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006007/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006008/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006009/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006010/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006011/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006012QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006013 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6014 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6015
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006016 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6017 return Context.DependentTy;
6018
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006019 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6020 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6021 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6022 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6023 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6024 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6025 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6026 }
6027 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6028 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6029 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006030 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006031 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006032
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006033 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6034 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6035 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6036 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6037 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6038 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6039 // branch of the if, below.
6040 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6041 << dcl;
6042 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6043
6044 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6045 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6046 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6047 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006048 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6049 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6050 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6051 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6052 if (isSFINAEContext())
6053 return QualType();
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006054 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006055 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006056 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006057 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006058 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006059 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6060 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006061 return QualType();
6062 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006063 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006064 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6065 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6066 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006067 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006068 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006069 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006070 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006071 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006072 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006073 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6074 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6075 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6076 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6077 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006078 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6079 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006080 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6081 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006082 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6083 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006084 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006085 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006086 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6087 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
6088 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006089 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6090 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006091 return QualType();
6092 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006093 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006094 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006095 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006096 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006097 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6098 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006099 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006100 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006101 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6102 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006103 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006104 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6105 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6106 return QualType();
6107 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006108
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006109 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6110 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006111 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006112 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006113 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006114 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006115 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006116 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6117 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006118 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6119 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6120 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006121 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006122 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006123
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006124 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6125 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6126 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6127 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6128 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6129 }
6130
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006131 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
6132 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6133}
6134
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006135QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006136 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6137 return Context.DependentTy;
6138
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006139 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6140 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006141
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006142 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6143 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6144 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6145 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006146 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006147 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006148
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006149 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanian16b10372009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006150 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006151
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006152 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006153 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006154 return QualType();
6155}
6156
6157static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6158 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6159 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6160 switch (Kind) {
6161 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006162 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6163 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006164 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6165 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6166 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6167 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6168 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6169 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6170 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6171 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6172 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6173 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6174 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6175 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6176 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6177 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6178 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6179 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6180 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6181 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6182 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6183 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6184 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6185 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6186 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6187 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6188 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6189 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6190 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6191 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6192 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6193 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6194 }
6195 return Opc;
6196}
6197
6198static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6199 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6200 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6201 switch (Kind) {
6202 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6203 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6204 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6205 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6206 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6207 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6208 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6209 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6210 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006211 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6212 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
6213 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
6214 }
6215 return Opc;
6216}
6217
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006218/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6219/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6220/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006221Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6222 unsigned Op,
6223 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006224 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006225 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006226 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6227 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6228 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006229
6230 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006231 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6232 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6233 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006234 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6235 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6236 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6237 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6238 break;
6239 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006240 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006241 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6242 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006243 break;
6244 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6245 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6246 break;
6247 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6248 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6249 break;
6250 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6251 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6252 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006253 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006254 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6255 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6256 break;
6257 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6258 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6259 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6260 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006261 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006262 break;
6263 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6264 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006265 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006266 break;
6267 case BinaryOperator::And:
6268 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6269 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6270 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6271 break;
6272 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6273 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6274 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6275 break;
6276 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6277 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006278 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6279 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006280 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6281 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6282 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006283 break;
6284 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006285 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6286 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6287 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6288 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006289 break;
6290 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006291 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6292 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6293 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006294 break;
6295 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006296 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6297 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6298 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006299 break;
6300 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6301 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006302 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6303 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6304 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6305 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006306 break;
6307 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6308 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6309 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006310 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6311 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6312 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6313 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006314 break;
6315 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6316 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6317 break;
6318 }
6319 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006320 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006321 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006322 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6323 else
6324 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006325 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6326 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006327}
6328
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006329/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6330/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006331static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6332 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006333 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6334 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6335 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006336 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006337 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6338
6339 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6340 return;
6341
6342 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6343 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6344 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006345 return;
6346 }
6347
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006348 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6349 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006350 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006351
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006352 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006353 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006354
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006355 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6356 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6357 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6358 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006359 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006360 return;
6361 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006362
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006363 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006364 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6365 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006366}
6367
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006368/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6369/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6370/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6371/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006372static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6373 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006374 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6375 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6376 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6377 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006378 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006379 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006380 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6381
6382 // Subs are not binary operators.
6383 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6384 return;
6385
6386 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6387 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006388 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6389 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006390 return;
6391
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006392 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006393 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006394 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006395 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6396 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006397 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006398 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006399 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6400 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6401 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6402 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006403 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006404 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006405 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006406 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6407 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006408 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006409 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006410 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6411 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6412 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6413 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006414}
6415
6416/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6417/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6418/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6419static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6420 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006421 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006422 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6423}
6424
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006425// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006426Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6427 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6428 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006429 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006430 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006431
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006432 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6433 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006434
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006435 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6436 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6437
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006438 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6439}
6440
6441Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6442 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6443 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006444 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006445 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006446 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6447 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6448 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6449 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6450 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006451 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006452 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006453 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6454 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6455 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006456
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006457 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6458 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006459 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006460 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006461
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006462 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006463 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006464}
6465
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006466Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006467 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006468 ExprArg InputArg) {
6469 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006470
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006471 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006472 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006473 QualType resultType;
6474 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006475 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6476 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6477 break;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006478
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006479 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6480 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006481 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6482 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006483 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006484 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006485 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6486 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6487 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006488 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006489 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006490 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6491 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006492 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006493 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006494 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6495 break;
6496 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6497 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006498 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6499 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006500 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6501 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006502 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6503 break;
6504 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6505 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6506 break;
6507 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6508 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6509 resultType->isPointerType())
6510 break;
6511
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006512 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6513 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006514 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006515 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6516 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006517 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6518 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006519 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6520 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6521 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006522 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006523 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006524 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006525 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6526 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006527 break;
6528 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
6529 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006530 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006531 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006532 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6533 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006534 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006535 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6536 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006537 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006538 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6539 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006540 break;
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006541 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006542 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006543 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006544 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006545 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006546 resultType = Input->getType();
6547 break;
6548 }
6549 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006550 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006551
6552 InputArg.release();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006553 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006554}
6555
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006556Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6557 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6558 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006559 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006560 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6561 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006562 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6563 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6564 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6565 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006566 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006567 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006568 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6569 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6570 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006571
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006572 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6573 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006574
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006575 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6576}
6577
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006578// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6579Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6580 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6581 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6582}
6583
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006584/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006585Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6586 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6587 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006588 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattnerea29a3a2009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006589 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006590
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006591 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6592 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006593 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006594 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006595
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006596 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006597 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6598 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006599}
6600
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006601Sema::OwningExprResult
6602Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6603 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6604 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006605 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6606 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6607
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006608 bool isFileScope
6609 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006610 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006611 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006612
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006613 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6614 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6615 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006616
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006617 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6618 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6619 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006620
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006621 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6622 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6623 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6624 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6625 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006626
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006627 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006628 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006629 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006630
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006631 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6632 // expressions are not lvalues.
6633
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006634 substmt.release();
6635 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006636}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006637
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006638Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6639 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006640 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6641 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006642 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6643 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006644 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006645 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006646
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006647 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6648 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6649 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006650 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006651 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6652 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6653
6654 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6655 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6656 if (!Dependent
6657 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6658 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6659 << TypeRange))
6660 return ExprError();
6661
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006662 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6663 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006664 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6665 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006666 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006667 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6668 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006669
6670 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6671 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6672 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6673 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6674 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6675 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6676 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6677 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6678 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6679 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6680 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6681 if(!AT)
6682 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6683 << CurrentType);
6684 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6685 } else
6686 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6687
6688 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6689 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6690 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6691 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6692 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6693 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6694 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6695 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6696
6697 // Record this array index.
6698 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6699 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6700 continue;
6701 }
6702
6703 // Offset of a field.
6704 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6705 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6706 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6707 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6708 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6709 continue;
6710 }
6711
6712 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6713 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6714 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6715 return ExprError();
6716
6717 // Look for the designated field.
6718 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6719 if (!RC)
6720 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6721 << CurrentType);
6722 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6723
6724 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6725 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6726 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6727 // (clause 9).
6728 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6729 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6730 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6731 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6732 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6733 << CurrentType))
6734 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6735 }
6736
6737 // Look for the field.
6738 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6739 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6740 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6741 if (!MemberDecl)
6742 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6743 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6744 OC.LocEnd));
6745
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006746 // C99 7.17p3:
6747 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6748 //
6749 // We diagnose this as an error.
6750 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6751 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6752 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6753 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6754 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6755 return ExprError();
6756 }
6757
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006758 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6759 // the base class indirections.
6760 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6761 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6762 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6763 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6764 Paths)) {
6765 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6766 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6767 B != BEnd; ++B)
6768 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6769 }
6770
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006771 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006772 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006773 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6774 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6775 unsigned n = Path.size();
6776 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6777 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6778 } else {
6779 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6780 }
6781 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6782 }
6783
6784 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6785 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6786 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6787}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006788
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006789Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6790 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6791 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6792 TypeTy *argty,
6793 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6794 unsigned NumComponents,
6795 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6796
6797 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6798 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6799 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6800 return ExprError();
6801
6802 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6803 if (!ArgTInfo)
6804 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6805
6806 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6807 RPLoc);
6808 }
6809
6810 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6811 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6812
6813 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6814
6815 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6816 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6817 // a struct/union/class.
6818 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6819 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6820
6821 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6822 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6823
6824 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6825 // the offsetof designators.
6826 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6827 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6828 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6829 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6830
6831 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6832 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6833 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6834 // a system header!
6835 if (NumComponents != 1)
6836 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6837 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6838
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006839 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedmanc0d600c2009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006840 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006841
John McCalld00f2002009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006842 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6843 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6844 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006845
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006846 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6847 // leaks like a sieve.
6848 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6849 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6850 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6851 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6852 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6853 if (!AT) {
6854 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006855 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006856 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006857 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006858
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006859 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006860
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006861 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6862 // expression.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006863 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006864
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006865 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6866 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006867 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006868 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006869 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006870 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006871 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6872
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006873 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6874 OC.LocEnd);
6875 continue;
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006876 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006877
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006878 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006879 if (!RC) {
6880 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006881 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006882 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006883 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006884
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006885 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6886 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006887 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006888 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6889 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6890 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006891 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6892 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006893 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006894 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006895
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006896 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6897 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006898
John McCall1bcee0a2009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006899 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006900 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006901 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregor3f093272009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006902 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006903 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6904
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006905 // C99 7.17p3:
6906 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6907 //
6908 // We diagnose this as an error.
6909 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6910 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6911 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6912 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6913 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6914 return ExprError();
6915 }
6916
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006917 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6918 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006919 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006920 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006921 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006922 } else {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006923 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6924 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006925 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6926 // doesn't matter here.
6927 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006928 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006929 }
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006930 }
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006931 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006932
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006933 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6934 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006935}
6936
6937
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006938Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6939 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6940 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006941 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6942 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6943 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006944
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006945 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006946
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006947 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6948 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6949 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6950 return ExprError();
6951 }
6952
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006953 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6954 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006955}
6956
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006957Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6958 ExprArg cond,
6959 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6960 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6961 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6962 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6963 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006964
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006965 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6966
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006967 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006968 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006969 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006970 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006971 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006972 } else {
6973 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6974 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6975 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6976 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006977 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6978 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6979 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006980
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006981 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6982 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006983 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6984 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006985 }
6986
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006987 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6988 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006989 resType, RPLoc,
6990 resType->isDependentType(),
6991 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006992}
6993
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006994//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6995// Clang Extensions.
6996//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6997
6998/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006999void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007000 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7001 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7002 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
7003 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007004}
7005
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007006void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007007 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007008 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007009
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007010 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007011 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007012 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007013
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007014 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007015 QualType RetTy;
7016 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007017 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007018 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007019 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007020 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7021 } else {
7022 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007023 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007024 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007025
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007026 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007027
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007028 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7029 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7030 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007031 return;
7032 }
7033
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007034 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7035 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7036 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7037 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7038 return;
7039 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007040
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007041 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007042 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7043 // ^ * { ... }
7044 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007045 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7046 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007047
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007048 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007049 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007050 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7051 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7052 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7053 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007054 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7055 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7056 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7057 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7058 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007059 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007060 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007061
7062 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7063 // ^ fntype { ... }
7064 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7065 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7066 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7067 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7068 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7069 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7070 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007071 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007072 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007073 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007074
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007075 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7076 if (!Params.empty())
7077 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007078
7079 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007080 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007081
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007082 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007083 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7084 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7085 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7086 }
7087
7088 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7089 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007090 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007091 return;
7092
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007093 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7094 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7095
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007096 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007097 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7098 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7099
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007100 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007101 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7102 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7103 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7104
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007105 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007106 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007107 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007108}
7109
7110/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7111/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7112void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007113 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007114 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007115 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007116 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007117}
7118
7119/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7120/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007121Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7122 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007123 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7124 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7125 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007126
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007127 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007128
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007129 PopDeclContext();
7130
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007131 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007132 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7133 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007134
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007135 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007136 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007137
7138 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7139 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7140 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7141
7142 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7143 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7144
7145 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7146 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7147 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7148 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7149
7150 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7151 // preserve its sugar structure.
7152 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7153 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7154 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7155
7156 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7157 } else {
7158 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7159 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7160 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7161 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7162 FPT->isVariadic(),
7163 /*quals*/ 0,
7164 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7165 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7166 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7167 FPT->exception_begin(),
7168 Ext);
7169 }
7170
7171 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7172 } else {
7173 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7174 false, false, 0, 0,
7175 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7176 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007177
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007178 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007179 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7180 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007181 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007182
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007183 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007184 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007185 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007186
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007187 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007188
7189 bool Good = true;
7190 // Check goto/label use.
7191 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7192 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7193 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7194
7195 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7196 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7197 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7198 continue;
7199
7200 // Emit error.
7201 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7202 Good = false;
7203 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007204 if (!Good) {
7205 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007206 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007207 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007208
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007209 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007210 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7211 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7212 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007213
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007214 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7215 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007216 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007217 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007218}
7219
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007220Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7221 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7222 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007223 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007224 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7225 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007226
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007227 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007228
7229 // Get the va_list type
7230 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007231 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7232 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7233 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7234 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007235 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007236 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7237 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7238 } else {
7239 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7240 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007241 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007242 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007243 return ExprError();
7244 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007245
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007246 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7247 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007248 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7249 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007250 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007251 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007252
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007253 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007254 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007255
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007256 expr.release();
7257 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7258 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007259}
7260
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007261Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007262 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7263 // pointers on the target.
7264 QualType Ty;
7265 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7266 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7267 else
7268 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7269
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007270 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007271}
7272
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007273static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007274 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007275 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7276 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007277
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007278 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7279 if (!PT)
7280 return;
7281
7282 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7283 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7284 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7285 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7286 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7287 return;
7288 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007289
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007290 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7291 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7292 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7293 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007294
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007295 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007296}
7297
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007298bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7299 SourceLocation Loc,
7300 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007301 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7302 bool *Complained) {
7303 if (Complained)
7304 *Complained = false;
7305
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007306 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7307 bool isInvalid = false;
7308 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007309 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007310
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007311 switch (ConvTy) {
7312 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7313 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007314 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007315 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7316 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007317 case IntToPointer:
7318 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7319 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007320 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007321 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007322 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7323 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007324 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7325 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7326 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007327 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7328 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7329 break;
7330 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007331 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7332 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7333 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7334 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7335 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7336 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7337 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7338 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7339 // C++ semantics.
7340 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7341 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7342 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007343 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7344 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007345 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007346 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007347 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007348 case IntToBlockPointer:
7349 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7350 break;
7351 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007352 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007353 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007354 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007355 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007356 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7357 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7358 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007359 case IncompatibleVectors:
7360 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7361 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007362 case Incompatible:
7363 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7364 isInvalid = true;
7365 break;
7366 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007367
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007368 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7369 switch (Action) {
7370 case AA_Assigning:
7371 case AA_Initializing:
7372 // The destination type comes first.
7373 FirstType = DstType;
7374 SecondType = SrcType;
7375 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007376
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007377 case AA_Returning:
7378 case AA_Passing:
7379 case AA_Converting:
7380 case AA_Sending:
7381 case AA_Casting:
7382 // The source type comes first.
7383 FirstType = SrcType;
7384 SecondType = DstType;
7385 break;
7386 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007387
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007388 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007389 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007390 if (Complained)
7391 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007392 return isInvalid;
7393}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007394
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007395bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007396 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7397 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7398 if (Result)
7399 *Result = ICEResult;
7400 return false;
7401 }
7402
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007403 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7404
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007405 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007406 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7407 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7408
7409 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7410 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7411 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7412 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7413 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7414 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7415 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007416
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007417 return true;
7418 }
7419
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007420 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7421 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007422
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007423 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7424 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7425 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007426
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007427 if (Result)
7428 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7429 return false;
7430}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007431
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007432void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007433Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007434 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7435 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007436}
7437
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007438void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007439Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7440 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7441 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7442 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007443
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007444 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7445 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7446 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7447 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7448 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007449 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007450 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7451 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7452 I != IEnd; ++I)
7453 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7454 }
7455
7456 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7457 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7458 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7459 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7460 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7461 I != IEnd; ++I)
7462 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7463 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007464 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007465
7466 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7467 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7468 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7469 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007470 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007471 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7472 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7473 ExprTemporaries.end());
7474
7475 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7476 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007477}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007478
7479/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7480///
7481/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7482/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7483/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7484/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7485///
7486/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7487///
7488/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7489void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7490 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007491
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007492 if (D->isUsed())
7493 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007494
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007495 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7496 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7497 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7498 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007499 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007500 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007501 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007502 return;
7503 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007504
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007505 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7506 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007507
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007508 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7509 // an instantiation.
7510 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7511 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007512
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007513 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007514 case Unevaluated:
7515 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7516 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007517
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007518 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7519 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7520 // "used"; handle this below.
7521 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007522
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007523 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7524 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7525 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7526 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007527 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007528 return;
7529 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007530
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007531 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007532 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007533 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007534 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7535 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7536 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007537 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007538 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007539 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7540 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7541 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007542
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007543 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007544 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7545 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7546 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007547 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7548 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007549 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7550 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7551 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7552 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007553 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007554 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7555 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007556 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007557 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007558 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007559 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007560 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007561 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7562 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7563 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7564 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7565 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007566 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007567 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007568 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007569 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007570 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7571 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7572 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007573 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007574 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007575 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7576 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007577
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007578 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7579 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7580 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7581 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7582 Loc));
7583 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007584 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007585 Loc));
7586 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007587 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007588
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007589 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007590 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007591
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007592 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007593 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007594
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007595 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007596 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007597 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007598 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7599 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7600 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7601 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7602 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7603 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7604 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7605 }
7606 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007607
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007608 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007609
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007610 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007611 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007612 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007613}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007614
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007615namespace {
7616 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
7617 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
7618 // of when we're entering
7619 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7620 Sema &S;
7621 SourceLocation Loc;
7622
7623 public:
7624 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
7625
7626 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
7627
7628 bool VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7629 bool VisitRecordType(RecordType *T);
7630 };
7631}
7632
7633bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
7634 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7635 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7636 }
7637
7638 return Inherited::VisitTemplateArgument(Arg);
7639}
7640
7641bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitRecordType(RecordType *T) {
7642 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7643 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7644 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
7645 return VisitTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7646 Args.flat_size());
7647 }
7648
7649 return false;
7650}
7651
7652void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7653 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
7654 Marker.Visit(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
7655}
7656
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007657/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7658/// of the program being compiled.
7659///
7660/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007661/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007662/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7663/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7664/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7665/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007666/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007667/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007668///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007669/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7670/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7671/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7672/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007673bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007674 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7675 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7676 case Unevaluated:
7677 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7678 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007679
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007680 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7681 Diag(Loc, PD);
7682 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007683
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007684 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7685 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7686 break;
7687 }
7688
7689 return false;
7690}
7691
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007692bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7693 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7694 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7695 return false;
7696
7697 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7698 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7699 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7700 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007701
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007702 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007703 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007704 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7705 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007706 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007707 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7708 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7709 return true;
7710
7711 return false;
7712}
7713
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007714// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7715// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7716void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7717 SourceLocation Loc;
7718
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007719 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7720
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007721 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7722 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7723 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7724 return;
7725
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007726 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7727 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7728 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7729 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7730
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007731 // self = [<foo> init...]
7732 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7733 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7734 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7735
7736 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7737 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7738 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7739 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7740 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007741
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007742 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7743 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7744 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7745 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7746 return;
7747
7748 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7749 } else {
7750 // Not an assignment.
7751 return;
7752 }
7753
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007754 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007755 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007756
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007757 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007758 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007759 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007760 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7761 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7762 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007763}
7764
7765bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7766 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7767
7768 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007769 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007770
7771 QualType T = E->getType();
7772
7773 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7774 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7775 return true;
7776 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7777 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7778 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7779 return true;
7780 }
7781 }
7782
7783 return false;
7784}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007785
7786Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7787 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007788 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7789 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007790 return ExprError();
7791
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007792 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7793 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7794 return ExprError();
7795 }
7796
7797 return Owned(Sub);
7798}